Auto-commit of loaddefs files.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobeef4edf17f681b50d6a0a3fe7ac9eeec385e3eec
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
81 #include <unistd.h>
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
145 static int any_help_event_p;
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
189 /* Mouse movement.
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
238 static Time last_user_time;
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
247 static int x_noop_count;
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
265 enum xembed_info
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
270 enum xembed_message
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
384 #if 0
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
389 struct record
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
395 struct record event_record[100];
397 int event_record_index;
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
410 #endif /* 0 */
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
425 return 0;
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
446 return win;
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
494 /* return unless necessary */
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
550 /* Nothing to do. */
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
567 block_input ();
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
580 unblock_input ();
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
621 block_input ();
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
631 unblock_input ();
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
643 updated_window = NULL;
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
676 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
677 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
678 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
679 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
680 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
681 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
683 static void
684 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
686 struct window *w = updated_window;
687 struct frame *f;
688 int width, height;
690 eassert (w);
692 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
693 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
695 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
696 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
697 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
698 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
699 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
700 overhead is very small. */
701 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
702 && desired_row->full_width_p
703 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
704 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
705 width != 0)
706 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
707 height > 0))
709 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
711 block_input ();
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 0, y, width, height, False);
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
716 y, width, height, False);
717 unblock_input ();
721 static void
722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
724 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
725 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
726 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
727 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
728 struct face *face = p->face;
730 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
733 if (!p->overlay_p)
735 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
737 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
738 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
739 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
740 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 if (face->stipple)
742 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
743 else
744 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
746 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
747 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
748 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
749 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
750 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
752 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
755 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
757 if (sb_width > 0)
759 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
760 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
761 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
763 if (bx < 0)
765 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
766 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
767 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
768 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
769 bx = bar_area_x;
770 if (bx >= 0)
772 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
774 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
775 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
776 row->y));
777 ny = row->visible_height;
780 else
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
784 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
787 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
792 #endif
793 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
794 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
796 if (!face->stipple)
797 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
800 if (p->which)
802 char *bits;
803 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
804 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
805 XGCValues gcv;
807 if (p->wd > 8)
808 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
809 else
810 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
812 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 by the server. */
814 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
815 (p->cursor_p
816 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
817 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
818 : face->foreground),
819 face->background, depth);
821 if (p->overlay_p)
823 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
824 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
825 bits, p->wd, p->h,
826 1, 0, 1);
827 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
828 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
829 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
830 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
833 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
834 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
835 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
837 if (p->overlay_p)
839 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
840 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
841 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
845 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
850 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
851 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
852 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 rarely happens). */
855 static void
856 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
860 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
861 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
863 static void
864 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
869 /***********************************************************************
870 Glyph display
871 ***********************************************************************/
875 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
878 int);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
883 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
884 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
889 unsigned long *, double, int);
890 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
891 double, int, unsigned long);
892 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
897 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
898 int, int, int);
899 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, int, int, int,
901 XRectangle *);
902 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
904 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
906 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1008 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1016 static void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1027 static void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1058 else
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1072 static void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1091 XRectangle r;
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1125 else
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1145 static void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1201 int i, x;
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1224 else
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1279 space on the left or right. */
1280 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1282 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1283 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1286 if (s->face->overstrike)
1287 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1290 else
1292 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1293 Lisp_Object glyph;
1294 int y = s->ybase;
1295 int width = 0;
1297 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1299 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1300 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1301 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1302 else
1304 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1306 if (j < i)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1311 x += width;
1313 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1314 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1315 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1319 x += wadjust;
1320 j = i + 1;
1321 width = 0;
1324 if (j < i)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1334 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1336 static void
1337 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1339 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1340 XChar2b char2b[8];
1341 int x, i, j;
1343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1344 of S to the right of that box line. */
1345 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1347 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1348 else
1349 x = s->x;
1351 s->char2b = char2b;
1353 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1355 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1356 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1358 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1360 if (len > 0
1361 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1362 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1363 >= 1))
1365 Lisp_Object acronym
1366 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1367 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1368 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1369 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1370 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1371 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1374 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1376 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1377 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1379 str = buf;
1382 if (str)
1384 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1385 unsigned code;
1387 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1388 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1390 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1391 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1393 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1394 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1395 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1402 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1404 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1405 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1406 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1407 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1413 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1414 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1415 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1416 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1418 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1420 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1421 cannot be determined. */
1423 static struct frame *
1424 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1426 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1427 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1428 struct frame *f;
1430 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1432 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1433 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1434 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1435 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1436 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1437 widget = XtParent (widget);
1439 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1440 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1441 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1443 f = XFRAME (frame);
1444 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1445 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1446 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1447 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1448 return f;
1450 emacs_abort ();
1453 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1454 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1455 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1456 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1457 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1458 Value is true if successful. */
1460 bool
1461 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1462 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1464 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1465 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1468 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1471 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1474 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1476 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1477 sizeof (Screen *)},
1478 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1479 sizeof (Colormap)}
1483 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1486 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1489 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1491 DPY is the display we are working on.
1493 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1494 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1495 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1496 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1498 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1499 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1501 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1502 we allocated the color or not.
1504 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1506 static Boolean
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1508 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1509 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1511 Screen *screen;
1512 Colormap cmap;
1513 Pixel pixel;
1514 String color_name;
1515 XColor color;
1517 if (*nargs != 2)
1519 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1520 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1521 "XtToolkitError",
1522 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1523 return False;
1526 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1527 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1528 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1530 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1532 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1533 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1537 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1538 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1540 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1541 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1543 pixel = color.pixel;
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1546 else
1548 String params[1];
1549 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1551 params[0] = color_name;
1552 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1553 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1554 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1555 params, &nparams);
1556 return False;
1559 if (to->addr != NULL)
1561 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1563 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1564 return False;
1567 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1569 else
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1572 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1575 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1576 return True;
1580 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1582 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1584 APP is the application context in which we work.
1586 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1587 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1588 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1590 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1592 static void
1593 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1594 Cardinal *nargs)
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1627 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1629 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1630 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 int i;
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1634 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1637 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1640 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1644 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1645 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1650 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1652 void
1653 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1679 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1683 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1684 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1685 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1686 allocated. */
1688 static bool
1689 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1691 bool rc;
1693 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1694 if (rc == 0)
1696 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1697 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1698 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1699 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1700 int nearest, i;
1701 int max_color_delta = 255;
1702 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1703 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1704 int ncells;
1705 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1707 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1709 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1710 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1711 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1712 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1714 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1716 nearest = i;
1717 nearest_delta = delta;
1721 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1722 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1723 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1726 else
1728 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1729 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1730 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1732 XColor *cached_color;
1734 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1735 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1736 (cached_color->red != color->red
1737 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1738 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1740 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1741 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1742 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1746 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1747 if (rc)
1748 register_color (color->pixel);
1749 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1751 return rc;
1755 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1756 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1757 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1758 allocated. */
1760 bool
1761 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1763 gamma_correct (f, color);
1764 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1768 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1769 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1770 get color reference counts right. */
1772 unsigned long
1773 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1775 XColor color;
1777 color.pixel = pixel;
1778 block_input ();
1779 x_query_color (f, &color);
1780 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1781 unblock_input ();
1782 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1783 register_color (pixel);
1784 #endif
1785 return color.pixel;
1789 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1790 boosted.
1792 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1793 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1794 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1795 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1796 use an additional additive factor.
1798 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1799 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1800 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1803 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1804 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1805 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1806 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1807 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1808 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1810 static bool
1811 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1813 XColor color, new;
1814 long bright;
1815 bool success_p;
1817 /* Get RGB color values. */
1818 color.pixel = *pixel;
1819 x_query_color (f, &color);
1821 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1822 eassert (factor >= 0);
1823 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1824 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1825 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1827 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1828 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1830 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1831 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1832 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1833 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1834 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1836 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1837 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1838 /* The additive adjustment. */
1839 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1841 if (factor < 1)
1843 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1844 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1845 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1847 else
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1855 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 if (success_p)
1859 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1861 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1862 delta to the RGB values. */
1863 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1868 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1870 else
1871 success_p = 1;
1872 *pixel = new.pixel;
1875 return success_p;
1879 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1880 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1881 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1882 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1883 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1884 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1886 static void
1887 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1889 XGCValues xgcv;
1890 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1892 unsigned long pixel;
1893 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1894 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1896 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1898 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1899 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1901 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1902 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1903 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1904 if (relief->gc
1905 && relief->allocated_p)
1907 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1908 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1911 /* Allocate new color. */
1912 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1913 pixel = background;
1914 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1915 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1917 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1918 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1921 if (relief->gc == 0)
1923 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1924 mask |= GCStipple;
1925 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1927 else
1928 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1932 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1934 static void
1935 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1937 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1938 unsigned long color;
1940 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1941 color = s->face->box_color;
1942 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1943 && s->img->pixmap
1944 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1945 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1946 else
1948 XGCValues xgcv;
1950 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1951 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1952 color = xgcv.background;
1955 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1956 || color != di->relief_background)
1958 di->relief_background = color;
1959 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1960 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1962 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1967 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1968 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1969 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1970 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1971 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1972 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1973 when drawing. */
1975 static void
1976 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1977 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1978 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1992 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1993 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1994 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1995 corner pixels. */
1997 /* Top. */
1998 if (top_p)
2000 if (width == 1)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2005 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2007 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2008 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2011 /* Left. */
2012 if (left_p)
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2017 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2018 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2020 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2021 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2022 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2023 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2026 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2027 if (raised_p)
2028 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2029 else
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2031 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2033 if (width > 1)
2035 /* Outermost top line. */
2036 if (top_p)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2039 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2041 /* Outermost left line. */
2042 if (left_p)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 if (bot_p)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2051 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2052 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2053 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2054 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2055 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2058 /* Right. */
2059 if (right_p)
2061 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2062 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2063 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2066 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2069 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2073 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2074 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2075 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2076 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2077 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2078 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2080 static void
2081 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2082 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2083 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2085 XGCValues xgcv;
2087 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2088 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2089 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2091 /* Top. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2095 /* Left. */
2096 if (left_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2100 /* Bottom. */
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104 /* Right. */
2105 if (right_p)
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2110 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2114 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2116 static void
2117 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2119 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2120 int left_p, right_p;
2121 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2122 XRectangle clip_rect;
2124 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2125 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2126 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2128 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2129 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2130 ? s->first_glyph
2131 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2133 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2134 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2135 left_x = s->x;
2136 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2137 ? last_x - 1
2138 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2139 top_y = s->y;
2140 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2142 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2143 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2144 && (s->prev == NULL
2145 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2146 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2147 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2148 && (s->next == NULL
2149 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2153 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2154 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2155 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2156 else
2158 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2159 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2160 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2165 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2167 static void
2168 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2170 int x = s->x;
2171 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2173 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2174 right of that line. */
2175 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2176 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2177 && s->slice.x == 0)
2178 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2183 x += s->img->hmargin;
2184 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2185 y += s->img->vmargin;
2187 if (s->img->pixmap)
2189 if (s->img->mask)
2191 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2192 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2193 trust on the shape extension to be available
2194 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2195 manually. */
2196 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2197 | GCFunction);
2198 XGCValues xgcv;
2199 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2201 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2202 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2203 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2204 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2205 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2207 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2208 image_rect.x = x;
2209 image_rect.y = y;
2210 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2211 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2212 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2213 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2214 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2215 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2217 else
2219 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2222 image_rect.x = x;
2223 image_rect.y = y;
2224 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2225 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2226 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2227 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2228 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2229 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2231 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2232 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2233 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2234 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2235 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2236 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2237 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2239 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2240 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2241 x - relief, y - relief,
2242 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2243 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2247 else
2248 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2250 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2254 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2256 static void
2257 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2259 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2260 XRectangle r;
2261 int x = s->x;
2262 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2265 right of that line. */
2266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2268 && s->slice.x == 0)
2269 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2271 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2272 by that margin. */
2273 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2274 x += s->img->hmargin;
2275 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2276 y += s->img->vmargin;
2278 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2279 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2281 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2282 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2284 else
2286 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2287 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2290 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2291 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2292 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2294 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2295 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2296 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2297 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2298 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2299 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2300 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2301 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2303 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2304 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2305 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2306 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2310 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2312 static void
2313 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2315 int x = 0;
2316 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2318 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2319 right of that line. */
2320 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2321 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2322 && s->slice.x == 0)
2323 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2325 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2326 by that margin. */
2327 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2328 x += s->img->hmargin;
2329 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2330 y += s->img->vmargin;
2332 if (s->img->pixmap)
2334 if (s->img->mask)
2336 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2337 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2338 trust on the shape extension to be available
2339 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2340 manually. */
2341 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2342 | GCFunction);
2343 XGCValues xgcv;
2345 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2346 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2347 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2348 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2349 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2351 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2352 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2353 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2354 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2356 else
2358 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2359 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2360 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2362 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2363 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2364 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2365 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2366 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2367 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2368 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2370 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2371 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2372 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2373 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2377 else
2378 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2379 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2380 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2384 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2385 give the rectangle to draw. */
2387 static void
2388 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2390 if (s->stippled_p)
2392 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2393 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2394 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2395 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2397 else
2398 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2402 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2404 s->y
2405 s->x +-------------------------
2406 | s->face->box
2408 | +-------------------------
2409 | | s->img->margin
2411 | | +-------------------
2412 | | | the image
2416 static void
2417 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2419 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2420 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2421 int height;
2422 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2424 height = s->height;
2425 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2426 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2427 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2428 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2430 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2431 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2432 flickering. */
2433 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2434 if (height > s->slice.height
2435 || s->img->hmargin
2436 || s->img->vmargin
2437 || s->img->mask
2438 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2439 || s->width != s->background_width)
2441 if (s->img->mask)
2443 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2444 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2445 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2446 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2447 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2449 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2450 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2451 s->background_width,
2452 s->height, depth);
2454 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2455 pixmap. */
2456 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2458 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2459 if (s->stippled_p)
2461 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2462 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2463 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2464 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2465 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2466 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2467 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2469 else
2471 XGCValues xgcv;
2472 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2473 &xgcv);
2474 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2475 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2476 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2477 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2480 else
2482 int x = s->x;
2483 int y = s->y;
2485 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2486 && s->slice.x == 0)
2487 x += box_line_hwidth;
2489 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2490 y += box_line_vwidth;
2492 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2495 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2498 /* Draw the foreground. */
2499 if (pixmap != None)
2501 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2502 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2503 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2504 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2505 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2507 else
2508 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2510 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2511 if (s->img->relief
2512 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2513 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2514 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2518 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2520 static void
2521 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2523 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2525 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2526 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2528 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2529 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2530 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2531 int x = s->x;
2533 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2535 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2537 if (x < left_x)
2539 background_width -= left_x - x;
2540 x = left_x;
2543 else
2545 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2546 stretch glyph. */
2547 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2549 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2550 background_width -= x - right_x;
2551 x += background_width;
2553 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2554 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2555 x -= width;
2557 /* Draw cursor. */
2558 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2560 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2561 if (width < background_width)
2563 int y = s->y;
2564 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2565 XRectangle r;
2566 GC gc;
2568 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2569 x += width;
2570 else
2571 x = s->x;
2572 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2573 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2575 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2576 gc = s->gc;
2578 else
2579 gc = s->face->gc;
2581 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2582 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2584 if (s->face->stipple)
2586 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2587 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2588 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2589 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2591 else
2593 XGCValues xgcv;
2594 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2595 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2596 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2597 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2601 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2603 int background_width = s->background_width;
2604 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2606 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2607 except for header line and mode line. */
2608 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2610 background_width -= left_x - x;
2611 x = left_x;
2613 if (background_width > 0)
2614 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2617 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2621 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2623 x0 wave_length = 2
2625 y0 * * * * *
2626 |* * * * * * * * *
2627 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2631 static void
2632 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2634 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2635 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2636 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2638 dx = wave_length;
2639 dy = wave_height - 1;
2640 x0 = s->x;
2641 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2642 width = s->width;
2643 xmax = x0 + width;
2645 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2647 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2648 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2650 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2651 return;
2653 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2655 /* Draw the waves */
2657 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2658 x2 = x1 + dx;
2659 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2660 y1 = y2 = y0;
2662 if (odd)
2663 y1 += dy;
2664 else
2665 y2 += dy;
2667 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2668 emacs_abort ();
2670 while (x1 <= xmax)
2672 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2673 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2674 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2675 odd = !odd;
2678 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2679 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2683 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2685 static void
2686 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2688 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2690 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2691 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2692 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2693 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2695 int width;
2696 struct glyph_string *next;
2698 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2699 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2700 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2701 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2703 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2704 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2705 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2706 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2707 else
2708 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2709 next->num_clips = 0;
2713 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2714 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2716 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2717 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2718 if (!s->for_overlaps
2719 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2720 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2721 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2724 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2725 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2727 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2728 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2730 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2731 && !s->clip_tail
2732 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2733 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2734 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2735 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2736 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2737 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2738 else
2739 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2741 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2743 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2744 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2745 break;
2747 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2748 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2749 break;
2751 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2752 if (s->for_overlaps)
2753 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2754 else
2755 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2756 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2757 break;
2759 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2760 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2761 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2762 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2763 else
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2765 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2766 break;
2768 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2769 if (s->for_overlaps)
2770 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2771 else
2772 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2773 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2774 break;
2776 default:
2777 emacs_abort ();
2780 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2782 /* Draw underline. */
2783 if (s->face->underline_p)
2785 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2787 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2788 x_draw_underwave (s);
2789 else
2791 XGCValues xgcv;
2792 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2793 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2794 x_draw_underwave (s);
2795 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2798 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2800 unsigned long thickness, position;
2801 int y;
2803 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2804 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2806 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2807 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2808 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2810 else
2812 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2813 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2814 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2815 else
2816 thickness = 1;
2817 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2818 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2819 else
2821 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2822 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2823 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2824 specs, and its default is
2826 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2827 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2829 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2830 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2831 position = s->font->underline_position;
2832 else if (s->font)
2833 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2834 else
2835 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2837 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2839 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2840 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2841 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2842 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2843 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2844 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2845 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2846 s->underline_position = position;
2847 y = s->ybase + position;
2848 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2849 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2850 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2851 else
2853 XGCValues xgcv;
2854 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2855 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2856 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2857 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2858 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2862 /* Draw overline. */
2863 if (s->face->overline_p)
2865 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2867 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2868 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2869 s->width, h);
2870 else
2872 XGCValues xgcv;
2873 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2874 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2875 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2876 s->width, h);
2877 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2881 /* Draw strike-through. */
2882 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2884 unsigned long h = 1;
2885 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2887 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2888 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2889 s->width, h);
2890 else
2892 XGCValues xgcv;
2893 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2894 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2895 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2896 s->width, h);
2897 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2901 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2902 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2903 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2905 if (s->prev)
2907 struct glyph_string *prev;
2909 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2910 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2911 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2913 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2914 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2915 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2917 prev->hl = s->hl;
2918 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2919 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2920 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2921 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2922 else
2923 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2924 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2925 prev->hl = save;
2926 prev->num_clips = 0;
2930 if (s->next)
2932 struct glyph_string *next;
2934 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2935 if (next->hl != s->hl
2936 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2938 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2939 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2940 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2942 next->hl = s->hl;
2943 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2944 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2945 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2946 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2947 else
2948 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2949 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2950 next->hl = save;
2951 next->num_clips = 0;
2952 next->clip_head = s->next;
2957 /* Reset clipping. */
2958 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2959 s->num_clips = 0;
2962 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2964 static void
2965 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2967 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2968 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2969 x, y, width, height,
2970 x + shift_by, y);
2973 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2974 for X frames. */
2976 static void
2977 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2979 emacs_abort ();
2983 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2984 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2986 void
2987 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2989 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2990 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2994 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2996 static void
2997 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2999 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3000 longer visible. */
3001 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3002 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3003 output_cursor.x = -1;
3005 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3006 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3007 block_input ();
3009 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3011 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3012 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3013 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3015 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3016 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3017 redisplay, do it here. */
3018 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3019 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3020 #endif
3022 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3024 unblock_input ();
3029 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3031 static void
3032 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3034 block_input ();
3037 #ifdef USE_GTK
3038 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3039 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3040 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3041 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3042 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3043 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3044 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3045 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3046 do { \
3047 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3048 cairo_fill (cr); \
3050 while (0)
3051 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3052 GdkGCValues vals;
3053 GdkGC *gc;
3054 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3055 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3056 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3057 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3058 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3059 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3060 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3061 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3062 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3063 GC gc;
3065 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3066 pixels into background pixels. */
3068 XGCValues values;
3070 values.function = GXxor;
3071 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3072 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3074 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3077 #endif
3079 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3080 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3081 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3082 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3083 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3084 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3085 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3087 int width;
3089 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3090 edge it is next to. */
3091 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3093 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3094 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3095 break;
3097 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3098 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3099 break;
3101 default:
3102 break;
3105 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3107 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3108 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3110 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3111 flash_left,
3112 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3113 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3114 width, flash_height);
3115 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3116 flash_left,
3117 (height - flash_height
3118 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3119 width, flash_height);
3122 else
3123 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3125 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3126 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3128 x_flush (f);
3131 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3132 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3134 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3135 available. */
3136 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3138 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3139 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3141 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3142 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3143 break;
3145 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3146 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3148 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3149 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3153 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3154 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3156 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3157 flash_left,
3158 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3159 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3160 width, flash_height);
3161 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3162 flash_left,
3163 (height - flash_height
3164 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3165 width, flash_height);
3167 else
3168 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3169 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3170 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3171 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3173 #ifdef USE_GTK
3174 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3175 cairo_destroy (cr);
3176 #else
3177 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3178 #endif
3179 #undef XFillRectangle
3180 #else
3181 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3182 #endif
3183 x_flush (f);
3187 unblock_input ();
3191 static void
3192 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3194 block_input ();
3195 if (invisible)
3197 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3198 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3199 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3201 else
3202 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3203 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3204 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3205 unblock_input ();
3209 /* Make audible bell. */
3211 static void
3212 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3214 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3216 if (visible_bell)
3217 XTflash (f);
3218 else
3220 block_input ();
3221 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3222 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3223 unblock_input ();
3229 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3230 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3231 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3232 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3234 static void
3235 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3237 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3242 /***********************************************************************
3243 Line Dance
3244 ***********************************************************************/
3246 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3247 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3249 static void
3250 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3252 emacs_abort ();
3256 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3258 static void
3259 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3262 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3264 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3265 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3266 fringe of W. */
3267 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3269 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3270 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3271 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3272 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3273 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3274 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3275 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3276 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3278 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3280 if (sb_width > 0)
3282 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3283 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3284 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3286 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3288 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3289 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3291 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3292 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3295 #endif
3297 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3298 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3299 bottom_y = y + height;
3301 if (to_y < from_y)
3303 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3304 line at the bottom. */
3305 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3306 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3307 else
3308 height = run->height;
3310 else
3312 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3313 at the bottom. */
3314 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3315 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3316 else
3317 height = run->height;
3320 block_input ();
3322 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3323 updated_window = w;
3324 x_clear_cursor (w);
3326 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3327 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3328 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3329 x, from_y,
3330 width, height,
3331 x, to_y);
3333 unblock_input ();
3338 /***********************************************************************
3339 Exposure Events
3340 ***********************************************************************/
3343 static void
3344 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3346 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3347 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3348 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3349 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3350 block_input ();
3351 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3352 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3353 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3354 because of this (bug#9310). */
3355 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3356 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3357 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3358 x_uncatch_errors ();
3359 unblock_input ();
3360 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3361 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3364 static void
3365 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3367 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3368 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3369 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3370 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3371 block_input ();
3372 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3373 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3374 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3375 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3376 x_uncatch_errors ();
3377 unblock_input ();
3378 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3379 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3382 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3383 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3384 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3385 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3386 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3388 static void
3389 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3391 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3393 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3395 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3396 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3397 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3399 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3400 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3402 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3403 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3404 else
3405 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3408 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3411 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3412 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3413 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3415 static void
3416 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3418 if (type == FocusIn)
3420 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3422 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3423 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3425 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3426 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3427 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3428 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3429 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3430 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3432 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3433 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3437 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3440 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3441 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3442 #endif
3444 else if (type == FocusOut)
3446 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3448 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3450 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3451 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3454 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3455 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3456 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3457 #endif
3458 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3459 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3463 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3464 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3466 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3468 static void
3469 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3471 struct frame *frame;
3473 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3474 if (! frame)
3475 return;
3477 switch (event->type)
3479 case EnterNotify:
3480 case LeaveNotify:
3482 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3483 int focus_state
3484 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3486 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3487 && event->xcrossing.focus
3488 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3489 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3490 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3491 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3493 break;
3495 case FocusIn:
3496 case FocusOut:
3497 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3498 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3499 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3500 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3501 break;
3503 case ClientMessage:
3504 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3506 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3507 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3508 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3510 break;
3515 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3516 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3518 void
3519 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3521 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3523 #endif
3525 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3526 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3527 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3529 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3530 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3531 the appropriate X display info. */
3533 static void
3534 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3536 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3539 static void
3540 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3542 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3544 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3546 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3547 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3548 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3549 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3550 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3552 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3553 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3556 else
3557 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3559 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3561 if (old_highlight)
3562 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3563 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3564 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3570 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3572 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3573 static void
3574 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3576 int min_code, max_code;
3577 KeySym *syms;
3578 int syms_per_code;
3579 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3581 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3582 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3583 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3584 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3585 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3587 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3589 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3590 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3591 &syms_per_code);
3592 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3594 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3595 Alt keysyms are on. */
3597 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3598 int found_alt_or_meta;
3600 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3602 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3603 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3605 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3607 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3608 if (code == 0)
3609 continue;
3611 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3613 int code_col;
3615 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3617 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3619 switch (sym)
3621 case XK_Meta_L:
3622 case XK_Meta_R:
3623 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3624 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3625 break;
3627 case XK_Alt_L:
3628 case XK_Alt_R:
3629 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3630 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3631 break;
3633 case XK_Hyper_L:
3634 case XK_Hyper_R:
3635 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3636 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3637 code_col = syms_per_code;
3638 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3639 break;
3641 case XK_Super_L:
3642 case XK_Super_R:
3643 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3644 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3645 code_col = syms_per_code;
3646 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3647 break;
3649 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3650 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3651 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3652 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3653 code_col = syms_per_code;
3654 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3655 break;
3663 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3664 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3666 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3667 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3670 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3671 make them just meta, not alt. */
3672 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3674 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3677 XFree (syms);
3678 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3681 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3682 Emacs uses. */
3685 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3687 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3688 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3689 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3690 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3691 Lisp_Object tem;
3693 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3694 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3695 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3696 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3697 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3698 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3699 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3700 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3702 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3703 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3704 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3705 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3706 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3707 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3710 static int
3711 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3713 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3714 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3715 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3716 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3718 Lisp_Object tem;
3720 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3721 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3722 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3723 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3724 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3725 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3726 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3727 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3730 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3731 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3732 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3733 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3734 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3735 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3738 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3740 char *
3741 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3743 char *value;
3745 block_input ();
3746 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3747 unblock_input ();
3749 return value;
3754 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3756 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3758 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3759 the mouse. */
3761 static Lisp_Object
3762 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3764 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3765 otherwise. */
3766 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3767 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3768 result->timestamp = event->time;
3769 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3770 event->state)
3771 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3772 ? up_modifier
3773 : down_modifier));
3775 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3776 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3777 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3778 result->arg = Qnil;
3779 return Qnil;
3783 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3784 The input handler calls this.
3786 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3787 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3788 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3789 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3791 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3792 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3794 static int
3795 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3797 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3798 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3799 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3801 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3802 return 0;
3804 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3806 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3807 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3808 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3809 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3810 return 1;
3814 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3815 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3816 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3817 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3818 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3819 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3821 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3822 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3823 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3824 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3825 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3826 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3827 return 1;
3830 return 0;
3834 /************************************************************************
3835 Mouse Face
3836 ************************************************************************/
3838 static void
3839 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3841 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3842 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3843 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3844 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3845 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3850 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3851 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3853 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3854 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3855 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3856 position on the scroll bar.
3858 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3859 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3860 the mouse is over.
3862 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3863 was at this position.
3865 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3867 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3868 movement. */
3870 static void
3871 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3872 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3873 Time *timestamp)
3875 FRAME_PTR f1;
3877 block_input ();
3879 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3880 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3881 else
3883 Window root;
3884 int root_x, root_y;
3886 Window dummy_window;
3887 int dummy;
3889 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3891 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3892 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3893 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3894 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3895 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3897 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3899 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3900 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3901 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3903 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3904 &root,
3906 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3907 a different screen. */
3908 &dummy_window,
3910 /* The position on that root window. */
3911 &root_x, &root_y,
3913 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3914 &dummy, &dummy,
3916 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3917 we don't care. */
3918 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3920 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3921 containing the pointer. */
3923 Window win, child;
3924 int win_x, win_y;
3925 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3927 win = root;
3929 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3930 structure is changing at the same time this function
3931 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3933 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3935 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3936 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3938 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3939 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3940 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3942 /* From-window, to-window. */
3943 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3945 /* From-position, to-position. */
3946 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3948 /* Child of win. */
3949 &child);
3950 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3952 else
3954 while (1)
3956 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3958 /* From-window, to-window. */
3959 root, win,
3961 /* From-position, to-position. */
3962 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3964 /* Child of win. */
3965 &child);
3967 if (child == None || child == win)
3968 break;
3969 #ifdef USE_GTK
3970 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3971 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3972 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3973 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3974 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3975 break;
3976 #endif
3977 win = child;
3978 parent_x = win_x;
3979 parent_y = win_y;
3982 /* Now we know that:
3983 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3984 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3985 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3986 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3987 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3988 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3989 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3990 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3991 never use them in that case.) */
3993 #ifdef USE_GTK
3994 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3995 want the edit window. */
3996 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3997 #else
3998 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3999 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4000 #endif
4002 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4003 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4004 on the frame. */
4005 if (f1 != NULL
4006 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4007 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4008 f1 = NULL;
4009 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4012 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4013 f1 = 0;
4015 x_uncatch_errors ();
4017 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4018 if (! f1)
4020 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4022 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4024 if (bar)
4026 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4027 win_x = parent_x;
4028 win_y = parent_y;
4032 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4033 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4035 if (f1)
4037 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4038 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4039 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4040 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4041 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4042 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4043 the frame are divided into. */
4045 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4046 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4048 *bar_window = Qnil;
4049 *part = 0;
4050 *fp = f1;
4051 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4052 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4053 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4058 unblock_input ();
4063 /***********************************************************************
4064 Scroll bars
4065 ***********************************************************************/
4067 /* Scroll bar support. */
4069 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4070 manages it.
4071 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4072 bits. */
4074 static struct scroll_bar *
4075 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4077 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4079 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4080 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4081 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4083 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4085 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4087 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4088 continue;
4090 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4091 right window ID. */
4092 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4093 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4094 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4095 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4096 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4097 condemned = Qnil,
4098 ! NILP (bar));
4099 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4100 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4101 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4102 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4105 return NULL;
4109 #if defined USE_LUCID
4111 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4112 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4114 static Widget
4115 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4117 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4119 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4120 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4122 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4124 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4125 return menu_bar;
4127 return NULL;
4130 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4133 /************************************************************************
4134 Toolkit scroll bars
4135 ************************************************************************/
4137 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4139 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4140 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4141 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4142 struct scroll_bar *);
4143 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4144 int, int, int);
4147 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4148 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4150 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4152 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4154 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4156 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4157 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4159 #ifndef USE_GTK
4160 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4162 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4164 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4166 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4167 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4168 to avoid jerkiness. */
4170 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4172 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4173 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4174 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4175 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4177 static void
4178 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4179 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4181 int scroll_bar_p;
4182 const char *end_action;
4184 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4185 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4186 end_action = "Release";
4187 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4188 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4189 end_action = "EndScroll";
4190 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4192 if (scroll_bar_p
4193 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4194 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4196 struct window *w;
4198 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4199 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4200 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4202 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4204 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4205 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4206 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4208 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4209 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4211 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4212 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4215 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4217 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4218 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4220 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4221 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4224 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4225 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4226 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4227 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4229 static void
4230 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4232 XEvent event;
4233 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4234 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4235 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4236 ptrdiff_t i;
4238 block_input ();
4240 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4241 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4242 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4243 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4244 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4245 ev->format = 32;
4247 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4248 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4249 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4250 into that array in the event. */
4251 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4252 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4253 break;
4255 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4257 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4258 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4259 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4260 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4261 scroll_bar_windows =
4262 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4263 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4264 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4265 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4268 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4269 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4270 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4271 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4272 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4273 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4275 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4276 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4277 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4278 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4279 #endif
4281 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4282 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4283 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4284 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4285 unblock_input ();
4289 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4290 in *IEVENT. */
4292 static void
4293 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4295 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4296 Lisp_Object window;
4297 struct window *w;
4299 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4300 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4302 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4304 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4305 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4306 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4307 #ifdef USE_GTK
4308 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4309 #else
4310 ievent->timestamp =
4311 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4312 #endif
4313 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4314 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4315 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4316 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4317 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4321 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4323 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4325 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4328 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4329 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4330 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4332 static void
4333 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4335 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4336 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4337 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4339 switch (cs->reason)
4341 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4342 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4343 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4344 break;
4346 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4347 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4348 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4349 break;
4351 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4354 break;
4356 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4359 break;
4361 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4364 break;
4366 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4369 break;
4371 case XmCR_DRAG:
4373 int slider_size;
4375 /* Get the slider size. */
4376 block_input ();
4377 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4378 unblock_input ();
4380 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4381 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4382 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4383 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4385 break;
4387 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4388 break;
4391 if (part >= 0)
4393 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4394 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4395 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4399 #elif defined USE_GTK
4401 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4402 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4404 static gboolean
4405 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4406 GtkScrollType scroll,
4407 gdouble value,
4408 gpointer user_data)
4410 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4411 gdouble position;
4412 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4413 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4414 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4416 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4417 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4420 switch (scroll)
4422 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4423 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4424 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4425 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4427 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4428 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4429 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4430 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4431 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4433 break;
4434 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4435 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4436 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4437 break;
4438 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4439 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4440 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4441 break;
4442 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4443 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4444 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4445 break;
4446 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4447 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4448 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4449 break;
4452 if (part >= 0)
4454 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4455 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4456 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4459 return FALSE;
4462 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4464 static gboolean
4465 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4466 GdkEventButton *event,
4467 gpointer user_data)
4469 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4470 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4471 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4473 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4474 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4475 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4478 return FALSE;
4482 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4484 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4485 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4486 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4487 the thumb is. */
4489 static void
4490 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4492 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4493 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4494 float shown;
4495 int whole, portion, height;
4496 int part;
4498 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4499 block_input ();
4500 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4501 unblock_input ();
4503 whole = 10000000;
4504 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4506 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4507 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4508 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4509 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4510 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4511 bottom). */
4512 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4513 else
4514 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4516 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4517 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4518 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4519 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4523 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4524 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4525 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4526 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4527 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4528 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4529 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4531 static void
4532 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4534 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4535 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4536 int position = (long) call_data;
4537 Dimension height;
4538 int part;
4540 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4541 block_input ();
4542 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4543 unblock_input ();
4545 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4546 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4548 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4549 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4550 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4551 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4552 else
4553 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4555 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4556 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4557 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4558 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4561 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4563 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4565 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4566 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4568 #ifdef USE_GTK
4569 static void
4570 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4572 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4574 block_input ();
4575 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4576 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4577 scroll_bar_name);
4578 unblock_input ();
4581 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4583 static void
4584 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4586 Window xwindow;
4587 Widget widget;
4588 Arg av[20];
4589 int ac = 0;
4590 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4591 unsigned long pixel;
4593 block_input ();
4595 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4597 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4598 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4599 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4600 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4601 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4602 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4603 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4605 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4606 if (pixel != -1)
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4609 ++ac;
4612 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4613 if (pixel != -1)
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4616 ++ac;
4619 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4620 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4622 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4623 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4624 (XtPointer) bar);
4625 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4626 (XtPointer) bar);
4627 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4628 (XtPointer) bar);
4629 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4630 (XtPointer) bar);
4631 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4632 (XtPointer) bar);
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4638 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4639 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4641 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4642 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4643 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4644 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4646 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4648 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4649 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4650 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4651 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4652 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4654 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4655 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4664 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4665 if (pixel != -1)
4667 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4668 ++ac;
4671 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4673 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4674 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4676 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4677 if (pixel != -1)
4679 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4680 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4681 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4682 pixel = -1;
4683 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4686 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4688 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4689 if (pixel != -1)
4691 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4692 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4693 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4694 pixel = -1;
4695 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4699 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4700 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4701 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4702 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4703 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4704 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4705 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4706 colors itself. */
4708 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4709 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4710 ++ac;
4712 else
4713 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4714 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4715 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4717 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4718 the shadows. */
4719 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4720 ++ac;
4722 /* Specify the colors. */
4723 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4724 if (pixel != -1)
4726 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4727 ++ac;
4729 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4730 if (pixel != -1)
4732 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4733 ++ac;
4736 #endif
4738 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4739 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4742 char const *initial = "";
4743 char const *val = initial;
4744 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4745 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4746 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4747 #endif
4748 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4749 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4750 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4751 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4752 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4753 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4757 /* Define callbacks. */
4758 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4759 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4760 (XtPointer) bar);
4762 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4763 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4765 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4767 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4768 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4769 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4770 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4772 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4773 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4774 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4775 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4777 unblock_input ();
4779 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4782 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4783 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4785 #ifdef USE_GTK
4786 static void
4787 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4789 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4792 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4793 static void
4794 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4795 int whole)
4797 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4798 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4799 float top, shown;
4801 block_input ();
4803 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4805 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
4807 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4808 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4809 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4810 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4811 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4812 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4813 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4814 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4815 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4816 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4817 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4818 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4819 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4820 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4821 whole += portion;
4824 if (whole <= 0)
4825 top = 0, shown = 1;
4826 else
4828 top = (float) position / whole;
4829 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4832 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4834 int size, value;
4836 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4837 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4838 value. */
4839 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4841 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4842 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4843 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4845 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4847 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4849 if (whole == 0)
4850 top = 0, shown = 1;
4851 else
4853 top = (float) position / whole;
4854 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4858 float old_top, old_shown;
4859 Dimension height;
4860 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4861 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4862 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4863 XtNheight, &height,
4864 NULL);
4866 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4867 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4868 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4869 else
4870 top = old_top;
4871 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4872 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4874 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4875 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4876 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4877 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4879 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4880 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4881 else
4883 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4884 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4885 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4887 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4891 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4893 unblock_input ();
4895 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4897 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4901 /************************************************************************
4902 Scroll bars, general
4903 ************************************************************************/
4905 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4906 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4907 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4908 scroll bar. */
4910 static struct scroll_bar *
4911 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4913 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4914 struct scroll_bar *bar
4915 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4916 Lisp_Object barobj;
4918 block_input ();
4920 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4921 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4922 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4924 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4925 unsigned long mask;
4926 Window window;
4928 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4929 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4930 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4932 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4933 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4934 | ExposureMask);
4935 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4937 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4939 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4940 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4941 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4942 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4943 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4944 left, top, width,
4945 window_box_height (w), False);
4947 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4948 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4949 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4950 top,
4951 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4952 height,
4953 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4955 CopyFromParent,
4956 CopyFromParent,
4957 CopyFromParent,
4958 /* Attributes. */
4959 mask, &a);
4960 bar->x_window = window;
4962 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4964 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4965 bar->top = top;
4966 bar->left = left;
4967 bar->width = width;
4968 bar->height = height;
4969 bar->start = 0;
4970 bar->end = 0;
4971 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4972 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4974 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4975 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4976 bar->prev = Qnil;
4977 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4978 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4979 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4980 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4982 /* Map the window/widget. */
4983 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4985 #ifdef USE_GTK
4986 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4987 bar->x_window,
4988 top,
4989 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4990 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4991 max (height, 1));
4992 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4993 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4994 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4995 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4996 top,
4997 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4998 max (height, 1), 0);
4999 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5000 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5002 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5003 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5004 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5006 unblock_input ();
5007 return bar;
5011 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5013 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5015 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5016 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5017 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5018 events.)
5020 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5021 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5022 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5023 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5024 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5026 static void
5027 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5029 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5030 Window w = bar->x_window;
5031 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5032 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5034 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5035 if (! rebuild
5036 && start == bar->start
5037 && end == bar->end)
5038 return;
5040 block_input ();
5043 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5044 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5045 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5047 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5048 the distance between start and end. */
5050 int length = end - start;
5052 if (start < 0)
5053 start = 0;
5054 else if (start > top_range)
5055 start = top_range;
5056 end = start + length;
5058 if (end < start)
5059 end = start;
5060 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5061 end = top_range;
5064 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5065 bar->start = start;
5066 bar->end = end;
5068 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5069 if (end > top_range)
5070 end = top_range;
5072 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5073 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5074 that many pixels tall. */
5075 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5077 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5078 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5079 if (0 < start)
5080 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5081 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5082 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5083 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5084 inside_width, start,
5085 False);
5087 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5088 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5089 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5090 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5092 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5093 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5094 /* x, y, width, height */
5095 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5096 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5097 inside_width, end - start);
5099 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5100 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5101 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5102 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5104 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5105 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5106 if (end < inside_height)
5107 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5108 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5109 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5110 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5111 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5112 False);
5116 unblock_input ();
5119 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5121 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5122 nil. */
5124 static void
5125 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5127 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5128 block_input ();
5130 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5131 #ifdef USE_GTK
5132 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5133 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5134 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5135 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5136 #else
5137 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5138 #endif
5140 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5141 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5143 unblock_input ();
5147 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5148 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5149 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5150 create one. */
5152 static void
5153 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5155 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5156 Lisp_Object barobj;
5157 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5158 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5159 int window_y, window_height;
5160 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5161 int fringe_extended_p;
5162 #endif
5164 /* Get window dimensions. */
5165 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5166 top = window_y;
5167 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5168 height = window_height;
5170 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5171 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5173 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5174 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5175 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5176 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5177 else
5178 sb_width = width;
5180 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5181 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5182 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5183 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5184 else
5185 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5186 #else
5187 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5188 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5189 else
5190 sb_left = left;
5191 #endif
5193 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5194 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5195 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5196 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5197 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5198 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5199 else
5200 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5201 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5202 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5203 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5204 #endif
5206 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5207 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5209 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5211 block_input ();
5212 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5213 if (fringe_extended_p)
5214 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5215 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5216 else
5217 #endif
5218 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5219 left, top, width, height, False);
5220 unblock_input ();
5223 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5225 else
5227 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5228 unsigned int mask = 0;
5230 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5232 block_input ();
5234 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5235 mask |= CWX;
5236 if (top != bar->top)
5237 mask |= CWY;
5238 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5239 mask |= CWWidth;
5240 if (height != bar->height)
5241 mask |= CWHeight;
5243 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5245 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5246 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5248 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5249 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5250 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5252 if (fringe_extended_p)
5253 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5254 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5255 else
5256 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5257 left, top, width, height, False);
5259 #ifdef USE_GTK
5260 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5261 bar->x_window,
5262 top,
5263 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5264 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5265 max (height, 1));
5266 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5267 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5268 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5269 top,
5270 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5271 max (height, 1), 0);
5272 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5274 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5276 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5277 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5278 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5280 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5281 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5282 height, False);
5283 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5284 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5285 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5286 height, False);
5289 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5290 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5291 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5292 example. */
5294 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5295 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5296 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5298 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5299 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5300 left + area_width - rest, top,
5301 rest, height, False);
5302 else
5303 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5304 left, top, rest, height, False);
5308 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5309 if (mask)
5311 XWindowChanges wc;
5313 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5314 wc.y = top;
5315 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5316 wc.height = height;
5317 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5318 mask, &wc);
5321 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5323 /* Remember new settings. */
5324 bar->left = sb_left;
5325 bar->top = top;
5326 bar->width = sb_width;
5327 bar->height = height;
5329 unblock_input ();
5332 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5333 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5335 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5336 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5337 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5338 dragged. */
5339 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5341 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5343 if (whole == 0)
5344 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5345 else
5347 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5348 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5349 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5352 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5354 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5355 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5359 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5360 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5361 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5362 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5363 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5364 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5365 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5367 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5368 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5369 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5371 static void
5372 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5374 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5375 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5377 Lisp_Object bar;
5378 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5379 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5380 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5381 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5382 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5383 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5384 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5389 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5390 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5392 static void
5393 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5395 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5396 struct frame *f;
5397 Lisp_Object barobj;
5399 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5400 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5401 emacs_abort ();
5403 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5405 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5406 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5407 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5409 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5410 the lists. */
5411 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5412 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5413 return;
5414 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5415 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5416 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5417 else
5418 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5419 one or the other! */
5420 emacs_abort ();
5422 else
5423 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5425 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5426 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5428 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5429 bar->prev = Qnil;
5430 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5431 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5432 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5433 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5436 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5437 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5439 static void
5440 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5442 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5444 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5446 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5447 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5448 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5450 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5452 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5454 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5456 next = b->next;
5457 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5460 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5461 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5465 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5466 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5467 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5469 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5470 mark bits. */
5472 static void
5473 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5475 Window w = bar->x_window;
5476 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5477 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5478 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5480 block_input ();
5482 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5484 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5485 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5486 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5487 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5489 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5490 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5492 /* x, y, width, height */
5493 0, 0,
5494 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5495 bar->height - 1);
5497 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5498 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5499 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5500 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5502 unblock_input ();
5505 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5507 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5508 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5510 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5511 mark bits. */
5514 static void
5515 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5517 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5518 emacs_abort ();
5520 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5521 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5522 emacs_event->modifiers
5523 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5524 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5525 event->xbutton.state)
5526 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5527 ? up_modifier
5528 : down_modifier));
5529 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5530 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5531 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5533 int top_range
5534 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5535 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5537 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5538 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5540 if (y < bar->start)
5541 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5542 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5543 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5544 else
5545 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5547 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5548 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5549 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5550 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5552 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5553 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5555 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5556 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5558 #endif
5560 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5561 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5565 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5567 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5569 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5570 mark bits. */
5572 static void
5573 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5575 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5577 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5579 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5580 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5582 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5583 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5585 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5586 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5588 if (new_start != bar->start)
5590 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5592 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5597 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5599 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5600 on the scroll bar. */
5602 static void
5603 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5604 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5605 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5607 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5608 Window w = bar->x_window;
5609 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5610 int win_x, win_y;
5611 Window dummy_window;
5612 int dummy_coord;
5613 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5615 block_input ();
5617 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5618 report that. */
5619 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5621 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5622 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5623 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5625 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5626 &win_x, &win_y,
5628 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5629 &dummy_mask))
5631 else
5633 int top_range
5634 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5636 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5638 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5639 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5641 if (win_y < 0)
5642 win_y = 0;
5643 if (win_y > top_range)
5644 win_y = top_range;
5646 *fp = f;
5647 *bar_window = bar->window;
5649 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5650 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5651 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5652 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5653 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5654 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5655 else
5656 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5658 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5659 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5661 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5662 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5665 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5667 unblock_input ();
5671 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5672 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5673 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5674 redraw them. */
5676 static void
5677 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5679 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5680 Lisp_Object bar;
5682 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5683 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5684 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5685 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5686 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5687 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5688 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5689 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5690 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5691 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5695 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5697 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5698 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5699 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5700 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5702 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5703 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5705 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5707 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5708 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5710 static int temp_index;
5711 static short temp_buffer[100];
5713 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5714 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5715 temp_index = 0; \
5716 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5718 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5719 on a particular display. */
5721 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5723 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5724 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5725 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5726 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5728 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5730 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5731 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5732 do \
5734 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5735 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5736 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5737 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5738 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5739 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5741 while (0)
5742 #endif
5744 enum
5746 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5747 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5748 X_EVENT_DROP
5751 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5752 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5753 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5755 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5756 this event further.
5757 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5759 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5760 static int
5761 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5763 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5764 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5765 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5766 was created. */
5768 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5769 event->xclient.window);
5771 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5773 #endif
5775 #ifdef USE_GTK
5776 static int current_count;
5777 static int current_finish;
5778 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5780 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5781 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5782 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5783 static GdkFilterReturn
5784 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5786 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5788 block_input ();
5789 if (current_count >= 0)
5791 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5793 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5795 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5796 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5797 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5798 so we do it here. */
5799 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5800 && dpyinfo
5801 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5803 unblock_input ();
5804 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5806 #endif
5808 if (! dpyinfo)
5809 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5810 else
5811 current_count +=
5812 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5813 current_hold_quit);
5815 else
5816 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5818 unblock_input ();
5820 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5821 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5823 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5825 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5828 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5829 enum xembed_message,
5830 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5832 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5834 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5835 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5836 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5838 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5840 static int
5841 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5842 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5844 union {
5845 struct input_event ie;
5846 struct selection_input_event sie;
5847 } inev;
5848 int count = 0;
5849 int do_help = 0;
5850 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5851 struct frame *f = NULL;
5852 struct coding_system coding;
5853 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5854 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5855 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5857 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5859 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5860 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5861 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5863 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5864 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5866 switch (event.type)
5868 case ClientMessage:
5870 if (event.xclient.message_type
5871 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5872 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5874 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5875 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5877 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5878 could be the shell widget window
5879 if the frame has no title bar. */
5880 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5881 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5882 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5883 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5884 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5885 #endif
5886 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5887 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5888 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5889 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5890 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5891 needed.
5893 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5894 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5895 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5896 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5897 Emacs. */
5899 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5900 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5901 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5902 if (f)
5904 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5905 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5906 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5907 x_catch_errors (d);
5908 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5909 /* The ICCCM says this is
5910 the only valid choice. */
5911 RevertToParent,
5912 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5913 /* This is needed to detect the error
5914 if there is an error. */
5915 XSync (d, False);
5916 x_uncatch_errors ();
5918 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5919 #endif /* 0 */
5920 goto done;
5923 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5924 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5926 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5927 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5928 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5929 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5930 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5931 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5932 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5933 session manager and one for this. */
5934 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5935 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5936 #endif
5938 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5939 event.xclient.window);
5940 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5941 for a single Emacs process. */
5942 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5943 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5944 event.xclient.window,
5945 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5946 else if (f)
5947 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5948 event.xclient.window,
5949 0, 0);
5951 goto done;
5954 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5955 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5957 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5958 event.xclient.window);
5959 if (!f)
5960 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5962 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5963 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5964 goto done;
5967 goto done;
5970 if (event.xclient.message_type
5971 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5973 goto done;
5976 if (event.xclient.message_type
5977 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5979 int new_x, new_y;
5980 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5982 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5983 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5985 if (f)
5987 f->left_pos = new_x;
5988 f->top_pos = new_y;
5990 goto done;
5993 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5994 if (event.xclient.message_type
5995 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5997 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5998 if (f)
5999 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6000 &event, NULL);
6001 goto done;
6003 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6005 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6006 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6007 || (event.xclient.message_type
6008 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6010 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6011 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6012 currently never do because we are interested in
6013 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6014 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6015 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6016 if (!f)
6017 goto OTHER;
6018 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6019 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6020 goto done;
6023 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6024 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6025 we construct an input_event. */
6026 if (event.xclient.message_type
6027 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6029 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6030 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6031 goto done;
6033 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6035 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6036 if (event.xclient.message_type
6037 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6039 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6040 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6041 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6043 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6044 goto done;
6047 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6049 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6050 if (!f)
6051 goto OTHER;
6052 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6053 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6055 break;
6057 case SelectionNotify:
6058 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6059 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6060 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6061 goto OTHER;
6062 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6063 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6064 break;
6066 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6067 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6069 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6073 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6075 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6076 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6077 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6078 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6080 break;
6082 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6083 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6084 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6085 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6086 goto OTHER;
6087 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6089 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6091 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6092 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6093 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6094 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6095 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6096 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6097 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6099 break;
6101 case PropertyNotify:
6102 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6103 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6104 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6105 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty)
6106 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6107 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6109 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6110 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6111 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6112 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6113 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6114 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6115 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6116 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6117 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6120 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6121 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6122 goto OTHER;
6124 case ReparentNotify:
6125 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6126 if (f)
6128 int x, y;
6129 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6130 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6131 f->left_pos = x;
6132 f->top_pos = y;
6134 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6135 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6136 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6138 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6140 goto OTHER;
6142 case Expose:
6143 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6144 if (f)
6146 #ifdef USE_GTK
6147 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6148 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6149 event.xexpose.window,
6150 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6151 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6152 FALSE);
6153 #endif
6154 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6156 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6157 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6158 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6159 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6161 else
6162 expose_frame (f,
6163 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6164 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6166 else
6168 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6169 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6170 #endif
6171 #if defined USE_LUCID
6172 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6173 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6174 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6176 Widget widget
6177 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6178 if (widget)
6179 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6181 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6183 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6184 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6185 goto OTHER;
6186 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6187 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6188 event.xexpose.window);
6190 if (bar)
6191 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6192 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6193 else
6194 goto OTHER;
6195 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6196 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6198 break;
6200 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6201 source area was obscured or not
6202 available. */
6203 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6204 if (f)
6206 expose_frame (f,
6207 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6208 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6209 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6211 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6212 else
6213 goto OTHER;
6214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6215 break;
6217 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6218 source area was completely
6219 available. */
6220 break;
6222 case UnmapNotify:
6223 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6224 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6226 tip_window = 0;
6227 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6230 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6231 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6232 the frame was deleted. */
6234 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6235 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6236 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6237 display that won't ever be seen. */
6238 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6239 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6240 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6241 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6242 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6243 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6244 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6245 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6247 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6248 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6249 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6252 goto OTHER;
6254 case MapNotify:
6255 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6256 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6257 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6258 goto OTHER;
6260 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6261 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6262 frame is visible. */
6263 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6264 if (f)
6266 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
6267 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6268 the frame's display structures.
6269 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6270 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6271 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6272 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6273 if (!iconified)
6274 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6276 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6277 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6278 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6279 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6281 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6282 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6283 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6285 if (iconified)
6287 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6288 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6290 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6291 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
6292 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
6293 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6295 #ifdef USE_GTK
6296 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6297 #endif
6299 goto OTHER;
6301 case KeyPress:
6303 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6304 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6306 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6307 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6308 if (popup_activated ())
6309 goto OTHER;
6310 #endif
6312 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6314 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6315 mouse highlighting. */
6316 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6317 && (f == 0
6318 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6320 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6321 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6324 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6325 if (f == 0)
6327 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6328 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6329 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6330 event.xkey.window);
6331 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6333 widget = XtParent (widget);
6334 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6337 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6339 if (f != 0)
6341 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6342 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6343 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6344 his Emacs hang.
6346 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6347 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6348 status_return even if the input is too long to
6349 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6350 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6351 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6352 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6353 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6354 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6355 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6356 int modifiers;
6357 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6358 Lisp_Object c;
6360 #ifdef USE_GTK
6361 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6362 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6363 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6364 (see above). */
6365 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6366 #endif
6368 event.xkey.state
6369 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6370 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6371 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6373 /* This will have to go some day... */
6375 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6376 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6377 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6378 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6379 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6380 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6381 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6383 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6384 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6385 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6386 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6387 not it is combined with Meta. */
6388 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6389 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6391 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6392 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6394 Status status_return;
6396 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6397 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6398 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6399 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6400 &status_return);
6401 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6403 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6404 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6405 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6406 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6407 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6408 &status_return);
6410 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6411 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6412 break;
6413 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6415 keysym = NoSymbol;
6416 modifiers = 0;
6418 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6419 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6420 emacs_abort ();
6422 else
6423 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6424 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6425 &compose_status);
6426 #else
6427 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6428 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6429 &compose_status);
6430 #endif
6432 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6433 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6434 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6435 break;
6437 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6438 orig_keysym = keysym;
6440 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6441 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6442 inev.ie.modifiers
6443 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6444 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6446 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6447 translations to characters. */
6448 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6449 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6451 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6452 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6453 goto done_keysym;
6456 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6457 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6459 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6460 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6461 else
6462 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6463 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6464 goto done_keysym;
6467 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6468 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6469 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6470 Vx_keysym_table,
6471 Qnil),
6472 NATNUMP (c)))
6474 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6475 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6476 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6477 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6478 goto done_keysym;
6481 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6482 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6483 || keysym == XK_Delete
6484 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6485 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6486 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6487 #endif
6488 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6489 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6490 #ifdef HPUX
6491 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6492 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6493 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6494 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6495 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6496 #endif
6497 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6498 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6499 #endif
6500 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6501 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6502 #endif
6503 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6504 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6505 #endif
6506 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6507 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6508 #endif
6509 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6510 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6511 #endif
6512 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6513 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6514 #endif
6515 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6516 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6517 #endif
6518 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6519 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6520 #endif
6521 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6522 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6523 #endif
6524 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6525 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6526 #endif
6527 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6528 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6529 #endif
6530 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6531 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6532 #endif
6533 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6534 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6535 #endif
6536 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6537 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6538 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6539 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6540 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6541 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6542 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6543 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6544 don't have real modifiers but
6545 should be treated similarly to
6546 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6547 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6548 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6549 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6550 #endif
6553 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6554 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6555 key. */
6556 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6557 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6558 goto done_keysym;
6561 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6562 ptrdiff_t i;
6563 int nchars, len;
6565 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6567 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6568 nchars++;
6569 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6572 if (nchars < nbytes)
6574 /* Decode the input data. */
6576 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6577 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6578 we used just above and the locale. */
6579 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6580 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6581 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6582 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6583 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6584 gives us composition information. */
6585 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6587 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6588 nbytes);
6589 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6590 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6591 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6592 nbytes = coding.produced;
6593 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6594 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6597 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6598 character events. */
6599 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6601 int ch;
6602 if (nchars == nbytes)
6603 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6604 else
6605 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6606 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6607 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6608 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6609 inev.ie.code = ch;
6610 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6613 count += nchars;
6615 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6617 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6618 break;
6621 done_keysym:
6622 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6623 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6624 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6625 client. */
6626 break;
6627 #else
6628 goto OTHER;
6629 #endif
6631 case KeyRelease:
6632 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6633 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6634 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6635 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6636 client. */
6637 break;
6638 #else
6639 goto OTHER;
6640 #endif
6642 case EnterNotify:
6643 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6644 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6646 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6648 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6649 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6651 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6652 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6653 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6654 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6655 #ifdef USE_GTK
6656 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6657 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6658 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6659 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6660 #endif
6661 goto OTHER;
6663 case FocusIn:
6664 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6665 goto OTHER;
6667 case LeaveNotify:
6668 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6669 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6671 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6672 if (f)
6674 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6676 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6677 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6678 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6679 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6682 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6683 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6684 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6685 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6686 if (any_help_event_p)
6687 do_help = -1;
6689 #ifdef USE_GTK
6690 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6691 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6692 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6693 #endif
6694 goto OTHER;
6696 case FocusOut:
6697 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6698 goto OTHER;
6700 case MotionNotify:
6702 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6703 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6704 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6706 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6707 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6708 f = last_mouse_frame;
6709 else
6710 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6712 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6714 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6715 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6718 #ifdef USE_GTK
6719 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6720 f = 0;
6721 #endif
6722 if (f)
6725 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6726 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6727 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6729 Lisp_Object window;
6731 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6732 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6733 0, 0);
6735 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6736 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6737 will be selected only when it is active. */
6738 if (WINDOWP (window)
6739 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6740 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6741 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6742 create event iff we don't leave the
6743 selected frame. */
6744 && (focus_follows_mouse
6745 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6746 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6748 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6749 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6752 last_window=window;
6754 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6755 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6757 else
6759 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6760 struct scroll_bar *bar
6761 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6762 event.xmotion.window);
6764 if (bar)
6765 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6766 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6768 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6769 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6770 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6773 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6774 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6775 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6776 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6777 do_help = 1;
6778 goto OTHER;
6781 case ConfigureNotify:
6782 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6783 #ifdef USE_GTK
6784 if (!f
6785 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6786 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6788 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6789 event.xconfigure.height);
6790 f = 0;
6792 #endif
6793 if (f)
6795 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6796 #ifndef USE_GTK
6797 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6798 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6800 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6801 is called by the code that handles resizing
6802 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6804 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6805 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6806 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6807 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6808 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6809 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6810 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6812 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6813 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6814 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6817 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6818 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6819 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6820 #endif
6822 #ifdef USE_GTK
6823 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6824 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6825 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6826 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6827 #endif
6829 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6832 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6833 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6834 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6835 #endif
6838 goto OTHER;
6840 case ButtonRelease:
6841 case ButtonPress:
6843 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6844 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6845 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6847 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6848 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6849 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6851 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6852 && last_mouse_frame
6853 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6854 f = last_mouse_frame;
6855 else
6856 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6858 #ifdef USE_GTK
6859 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6860 f = 0;
6861 #endif
6862 if (f)
6864 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6865 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6866 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6868 Lisp_Object window;
6869 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6870 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6872 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6873 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6875 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6877 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6878 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6879 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6880 event.xbutton.state));
6884 if (!tool_bar_p)
6885 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6886 if (! popup_activated ())
6887 #endif
6889 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6891 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6892 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6894 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6895 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6897 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6898 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6900 else
6901 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6903 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6904 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6905 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6907 else
6909 struct scroll_bar *bar
6910 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6911 event.xbutton.window);
6913 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6914 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6915 scroll bars. */
6916 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6918 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6919 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6921 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6922 if (bar)
6923 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6924 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6927 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6929 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6930 last_mouse_frame = f;
6932 if (!tool_bar_p)
6933 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6935 else
6936 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6938 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6939 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6940 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6941 if (f != 0)
6942 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6944 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6945 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6946 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6947 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6948 Instead, save it away
6949 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6950 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6951 if (! popup_activated ()
6952 #ifdef USE_GTK
6953 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6954 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6955 #endif
6956 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6957 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6958 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6959 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6960 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6961 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6962 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6963 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6965 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6966 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6967 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6969 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6971 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6972 goto OTHER;
6974 else
6975 goto OTHER;
6976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6978 break;
6980 case CirculateNotify:
6981 goto OTHER;
6983 case CirculateRequest:
6984 goto OTHER;
6986 case VisibilityNotify:
6987 goto OTHER;
6989 case MappingNotify:
6990 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6991 local cache. */
6992 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6994 case MappingModifier:
6995 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6996 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6997 case MappingKeyboard:
6998 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7000 goto OTHER;
7002 case DestroyNotify:
7003 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7004 break;
7006 default:
7007 OTHER:
7008 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7009 block_input ();
7010 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7011 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7012 unblock_input ();
7013 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7014 break;
7017 done:
7018 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7020 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7021 count++;
7024 if (do_help
7025 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7027 Lisp_Object frame;
7029 if (f)
7030 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7031 else
7032 frame = Qnil;
7034 if (do_help > 0)
7036 any_help_event_p = 1;
7037 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7038 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7040 else
7042 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7043 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7045 count++;
7048 SAFE_FREE ();
7049 *eventptr = event;
7050 return count;
7053 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7055 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7056 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7057 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7059 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7061 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7063 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7064 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7066 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7068 if (dpyinfo)
7069 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7071 return finish;
7073 #endif
7076 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7077 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7079 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7080 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7081 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7082 C chars). */
7084 static int
7085 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7087 int count = 0;
7088 int event_found = 0;
7090 block_input ();
7092 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7093 input_signal_count++;
7095 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7096 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7098 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7099 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7102 #ifndef USE_GTK
7103 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7105 int finish;
7106 XEvent event;
7108 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7110 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7111 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7112 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7113 continue;
7114 #endif
7115 event_found = 1;
7117 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7118 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7120 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7121 goto out;
7124 out:;
7126 #else /* USE_GTK */
7128 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7129 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7130 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7131 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7133 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7134 from all displays. */
7136 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7138 current_count = count;
7139 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7141 gtk_main_iteration ();
7143 count = current_count;
7144 current_count = -1;
7145 current_hold_quit = 0;
7147 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7148 break;
7150 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7152 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7153 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7154 if (! event_found)
7156 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7157 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7158 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7159 x_noop_count++;
7160 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7162 x_noop_count=0;
7164 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7165 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7167 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7169 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7170 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7174 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7175 raise it now. */
7176 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7177 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7179 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7180 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7183 unblock_input ();
7185 return count;
7191 /***********************************************************************
7192 Text Cursor
7193 ***********************************************************************/
7195 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7196 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7198 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7199 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7200 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7202 static void
7203 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7205 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7206 XRectangle clip_rect;
7207 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7209 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7211 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7212 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7213 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7214 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7215 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7217 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7221 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7223 static void
7224 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7226 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7227 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7228 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7229 int x, y, wd, h;
7230 XGCValues xgcv;
7231 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7232 GC gc;
7234 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7235 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7236 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7237 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7238 return;
7240 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7241 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7242 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7244 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7245 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7246 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7247 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7248 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7249 else
7250 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7251 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7252 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7254 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7255 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7256 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7257 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7261 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7263 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7264 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7265 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7266 --gerd. */
7268 static void
7269 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7271 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7272 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7274 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7275 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7276 and mini-buffer. */
7277 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7278 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7279 return;
7281 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7282 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7283 the bar might not be in the window. */
7284 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7286 struct glyph_row *r;
7287 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7288 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7290 else
7292 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7293 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7294 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7295 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7296 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7297 XGCValues xgcv;
7299 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7300 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7301 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7302 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7303 that the glyph is legible. */
7304 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7305 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7306 else
7307 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7308 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7310 if (gc)
7311 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7312 else
7314 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7315 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7318 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7320 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7322 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7324 if (width < 0)
7325 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7326 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7328 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7330 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7331 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7332 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7333 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7335 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7336 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7337 width, row->height);
7339 else
7341 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7343 if (width < 0)
7344 width = row->height;
7346 width = min (row->height, width);
7348 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7349 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7351 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7352 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7353 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7354 row->height - width),
7355 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7358 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7363 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7365 static void
7366 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7368 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7369 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7370 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7371 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7375 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7377 static void
7378 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7380 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7381 x, y, width, height, False);
7382 #ifdef USE_GTK
7383 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7384 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7385 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7386 #endif
7390 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7392 static void
7393 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7395 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7397 if (on_p)
7399 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7400 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7402 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7403 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7404 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7405 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7407 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7408 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7410 else
7412 switch (cursor_type)
7414 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7415 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7416 break;
7418 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7419 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7420 break;
7422 case BAR_CURSOR:
7423 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7424 break;
7426 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7427 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7428 break;
7430 case NO_CURSOR:
7431 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7432 break;
7434 default:
7435 emacs_abort ();
7439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7440 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7441 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7442 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7443 #endif
7446 #ifndef XFlush
7447 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7448 #endif
7452 /* Icons. */
7454 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7457 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7459 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7461 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7462 return 1;
7464 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7465 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7466 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7467 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7469 if (STRINGP (file))
7471 #ifdef USE_GTK
7472 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7473 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7474 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7475 return 0;
7476 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7477 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7478 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7480 else
7482 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7483 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7485 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7487 #ifdef USE_GTK
7489 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7490 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7491 return 0;
7493 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7495 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7496 if (rc != -1)
7497 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7499 #endif
7501 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7502 if (rc == -1)
7504 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7505 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7506 if (rc == -1)
7507 return 1;
7509 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7510 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7514 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7515 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7516 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7517 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7518 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7520 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7523 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7524 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7526 return 0;
7530 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7531 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7534 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7536 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7537 return 1;
7540 XTextProperty text;
7541 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7542 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7543 text.format = 8;
7544 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7545 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7548 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7549 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7550 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7551 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7553 return 0;
7556 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7558 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7559 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7561 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7562 be called from a signal handler.
7565 struct x_error_message_stack {
7566 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7567 Display *dpy;
7568 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7570 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7572 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7573 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7574 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7576 static void
7577 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7579 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7580 x_error_message->string,
7581 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7584 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7585 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7586 operating on.
7588 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7589 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7590 stored in *x_error_message.
7592 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7593 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7595 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7597 void
7598 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7600 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7602 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7603 XSync (dpy, False);
7605 data->dpy = dpy;
7606 data->string[0] = 0;
7607 data->prev = x_error_message;
7608 x_error_message = data;
7611 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7612 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7614 void
7615 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7617 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7619 block_input ();
7621 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7622 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7623 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7624 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7626 tmp = x_error_message;
7627 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7628 xfree (tmp);
7629 unblock_input ();
7632 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7633 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7634 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7636 void
7637 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7639 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7640 XSync (dpy, False);
7642 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7644 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7645 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7646 x_uncatch_errors ();
7647 error (format, string);
7651 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7652 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7655 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7657 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7658 XSync (dpy, False);
7660 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7663 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7665 void
7666 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7668 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7671 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7672 * idea. --lorentey */
7673 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7675 void
7676 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7678 while (x_error_message)
7679 x_uncatch_errors ();
7681 #endif
7683 #if 0
7684 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7685 x_trace_wire (void)
7687 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7689 #endif /* ! 0 */
7692 /************************************************************************
7693 Handling X errors
7694 ************************************************************************/
7696 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7698 static char *error_msg;
7700 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7701 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7703 static void
7704 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7706 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7707 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7708 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7710 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7711 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7713 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7714 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7716 if (dpyinfo)
7718 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7719 frame on it. */
7720 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7721 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7724 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7725 that are on the dead display. */
7726 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7728 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7729 minibuf_frame
7730 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7731 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7732 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7733 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7734 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7735 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7738 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7739 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7740 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7741 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7742 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7743 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7745 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7746 trying to find a replacement. */
7747 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7748 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7751 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7752 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7753 if (dpyinfo)
7755 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7756 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7757 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7758 #ifdef USE_GTK
7759 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7760 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7761 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7762 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7763 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7764 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7765 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7766 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7767 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7768 error_msg);
7769 emacs_abort ();
7770 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7772 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7773 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7775 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7776 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7777 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7778 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7779 emacs_abort ();
7782 Lisp_Object tmp;
7783 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7784 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7788 if (terminal_list == 0)
7790 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7791 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7792 /* NOTREACHED */
7795 totally_unblock_input ();
7797 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7798 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7800 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7801 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7803 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7804 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7805 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7806 error ("%s", error_msg);
7809 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7810 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7811 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7813 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7814 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7816 static int
7817 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7819 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7820 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7821 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7822 && event->minor_code == 0)
7824 return 0;
7826 #endif
7828 if (x_error_message)
7829 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7830 else
7831 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7832 return 0;
7835 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7836 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7837 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7839 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7841 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7842 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7844 static void NO_INLINE
7845 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7847 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7849 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7850 or colors that are not defined. */
7852 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7853 return;
7855 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7856 original error handler. */
7858 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7859 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7860 buf, event->request_code);
7861 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7865 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7866 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7867 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7869 static int
7870 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7872 char buf[256];
7874 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7875 DisplayString (display));
7876 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7877 return 0;
7880 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7882 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7883 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7884 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7885 FONT-OBJECT. */
7887 Lisp_Object
7888 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7890 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7892 if (fontset < 0)
7893 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7894 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7895 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7896 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7897 do. */
7898 return font_object;
7900 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7901 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7902 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7903 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7905 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7907 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7908 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7910 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7911 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7912 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7914 else
7916 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7917 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7920 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7922 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7923 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7924 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7925 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7926 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7929 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7930 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7931 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7933 block_input ();
7934 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7935 unblock_input ();
7937 #endif
7939 return font_object;
7943 /***********************************************************************
7944 X Input Methods
7945 ***********************************************************************/
7947 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7949 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7951 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7952 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7953 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7955 static void
7956 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7958 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7959 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7961 block_input ();
7963 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7964 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7966 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7967 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7969 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7970 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7974 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7975 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7976 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7977 unblock_input ();
7980 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7982 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7983 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7984 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7985 #endif
7987 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7988 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7990 static void
7991 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7993 XIM xim;
7995 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7996 if (use_xim)
7998 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7999 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8000 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8001 emacs_class);
8002 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8004 if (xim)
8006 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8007 XIMCallback destroy;
8008 #endif
8010 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8011 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8013 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8014 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8015 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8016 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8017 #endif
8021 else
8022 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8023 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8027 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8029 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8030 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8031 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8032 when the callback was registered. */
8034 static void
8035 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8037 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8038 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8040 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8041 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8042 return;
8044 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8046 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8047 as they have no XIC. */
8048 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8050 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8052 block_input ();
8053 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8055 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8057 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8058 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8059 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8061 create_frame_xic (f);
8062 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8063 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8064 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8066 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8067 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8072 unblock_input ();
8076 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8079 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8080 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8081 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8082 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8084 static void
8085 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8087 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8088 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8089 if (use_xim)
8091 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8092 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8093 ptrdiff_t len;
8095 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8096 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8097 len = strlen (resource_name);
8098 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8099 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8100 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8101 resource_name, emacs_class,
8102 xim_instantiate_callback,
8103 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8104 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8105 least, hence the configure test. */
8106 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8107 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8108 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8109 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8111 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8115 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8117 static void
8118 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8120 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8121 if (use_xim)
8123 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8124 if (dpyinfo->display)
8125 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8126 NULL, emacs_class,
8127 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8128 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8129 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8130 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8131 if (dpyinfo->display)
8132 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8133 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8134 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8136 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8139 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8143 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8144 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8146 static void
8147 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8149 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8151 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8152 is already for the top-left corner. */
8153 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8154 return;
8156 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8157 position that fits on the screen. */
8158 if (flags & XNegative)
8159 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8160 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8163 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8165 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8166 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8167 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8169 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8170 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8171 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8172 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8173 is right, though.
8175 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8176 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8178 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8179 #endif
8181 if (flags & YNegative)
8182 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8183 - height + f->top_pos;
8186 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8187 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8188 so the flags should correspond. */
8189 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8192 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8193 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8194 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8195 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8196 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8198 void
8199 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8201 int modified_top, modified_left;
8203 if (change_gravity > 0)
8205 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8206 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8208 f->top_pos = yoff;
8209 f->left_pos = xoff;
8210 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8211 if (xoff < 0)
8212 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8213 if (yoff < 0)
8214 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8215 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8217 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8219 block_input ();
8220 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8222 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8223 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8225 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8227 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8228 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8229 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8230 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8231 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8234 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8235 modified_left, modified_top);
8237 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8238 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8239 ? 1 : 0);
8241 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8242 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8243 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8244 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8245 of the frame.
8247 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8248 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8249 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8251 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8252 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8253 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8254 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8255 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8256 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8258 unblock_input ();
8261 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8262 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8263 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8264 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8265 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8267 static int
8268 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8270 Atom actual_type;
8271 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8272 int i, rc, actual_format;
8273 Window wmcheck_window;
8274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8275 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8276 long max_len = 65536;
8277 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8278 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8279 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8281 block_input ();
8283 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8284 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8285 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8286 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8287 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8288 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8290 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8292 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8293 x_uncatch_errors ();
8294 unblock_input ();
8295 return 0;
8298 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8299 XFree (tmp_data);
8301 /* Check if window exists. */
8302 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8303 x_sync (f);
8304 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8306 x_uncatch_errors ();
8307 unblock_input ();
8308 return 0;
8311 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8313 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8314 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8315 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8316 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8317 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8318 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8320 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8321 tmp_data = NULL;
8322 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8323 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8324 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8325 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8326 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8328 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8330 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8331 x_uncatch_errors ();
8332 unblock_input ();
8333 return 0;
8336 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8337 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8338 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8341 rc = 0;
8343 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8344 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8346 x_uncatch_errors ();
8347 unblock_input ();
8349 return rc;
8352 static void
8353 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8355 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8357 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8358 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8359 make_number (32),
8360 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8361 Fcons
8362 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8363 Fcons
8364 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8365 value != 0
8366 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8367 : Qnil)));
8370 void
8371 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8373 Lisp_Object frame;
8374 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8376 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8378 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8379 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8382 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8383 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8384 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8386 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8388 static int
8389 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8390 Window window,
8391 int *size_state,
8392 int *sticky)
8394 Atom actual_type;
8395 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8396 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8397 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8398 long max_len = 65536;
8399 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8400 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8401 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8403 *sticky = 0;
8404 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8406 block_input ();
8407 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8408 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8409 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8410 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8411 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8413 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8415 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8416 x_uncatch_errors ();
8417 unblock_input ();
8418 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
8421 x_uncatch_errors ();
8423 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8425 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8426 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8428 is_hidden = 1;
8429 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8431 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8433 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8434 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8435 else
8436 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8438 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8440 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8441 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8442 else
8443 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8445 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8447 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8448 *sticky = 1;
8451 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8452 unblock_input ();
8453 return ! is_hidden;
8456 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8458 static int
8459 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8461 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8462 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8463 int cur, dummy;
8465 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8467 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8468 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8469 if (!have_net_atom)
8470 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8472 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8474 Lisp_Object frame;
8476 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8478 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8479 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8480 are sent at once. */
8481 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8483 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8484 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8485 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8486 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8487 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8488 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8489 break;
8490 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8491 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8492 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8493 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8494 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8495 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8496 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8497 break;
8498 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8499 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8500 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8501 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8502 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8503 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8504 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8505 break;
8506 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8507 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8509 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8510 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8511 break;
8512 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8513 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8515 else
8516 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8517 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8520 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8524 return have_net_atom;
8527 static void
8528 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8530 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8532 block_input ();
8533 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8534 x_sync (f);
8535 unblock_input ();
8540 static int
8541 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8543 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8544 Lisp_Object lval;
8545 int sticky = 0;
8546 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8548 lval = Qnil;
8549 switch (value)
8551 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8552 lval = Qfullwidth;
8553 break;
8554 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8555 lval = Qfullheight;
8556 break;
8557 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8558 lval = Qfullboth;
8559 break;
8560 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8561 lval = Qmaximized;
8562 break;
8565 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8566 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8568 return not_hidden;
8571 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8572 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8573 static void
8574 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8576 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8577 return;
8579 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8580 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8582 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8583 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8584 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8586 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8588 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8589 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8591 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8593 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8594 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8595 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8596 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8597 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8598 break;
8599 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8600 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8601 break;
8602 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8603 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8606 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8607 width, height);
8611 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8612 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8613 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8614 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8615 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8616 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8617 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8619 static void
8620 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8622 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8624 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8625 window manager window around the frame. */
8627 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8629 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8631 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8633 int adjusted_left;
8634 int adjusted_top;
8636 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8637 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8638 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8640 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8642 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8643 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8645 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8646 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8648 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8650 else
8651 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8652 frame's position. */
8654 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8658 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8659 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8660 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8661 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8662 of an exact comparison. */
8664 static void
8665 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8667 int count = 0;
8669 while (count++ < 50)
8671 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8673 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8674 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8675 loop. */
8677 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8678 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8680 if (fuzzy)
8682 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8683 pixels. */
8685 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8686 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8687 return;
8689 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8690 return;
8693 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8694 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8696 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8700 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8701 void
8702 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8704 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8706 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8707 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8708 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8710 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8711 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8713 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8714 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8715 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8716 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8718 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8720 pending_signals = 1;
8721 totally_unblock_input ();
8722 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8723 block_input ();
8724 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8726 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8727 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8729 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8730 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8731 break;
8733 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8734 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8735 break; /* Timeout */
8737 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8738 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8742 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8743 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8744 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8745 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8747 static void
8748 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8750 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8752 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8753 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8754 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8756 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8758 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8760 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8761 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8762 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8763 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8765 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8766 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8767 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8768 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8771 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8772 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8773 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8774 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8775 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8777 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8778 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8779 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8780 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8782 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8783 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8784 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8785 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8786 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8788 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8789 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8791 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8792 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8793 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8794 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8795 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8796 else
8798 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8799 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8800 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8801 x_sync (f);
8806 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8807 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8808 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8809 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8811 void
8812 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8814 block_input ();
8816 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8818 int r, c;
8820 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8821 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8822 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8823 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8824 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8825 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8826 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8827 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8828 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8829 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8830 is however. */
8831 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8832 #endif
8833 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8834 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8835 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8836 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8837 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8838 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8839 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8842 #ifdef USE_GTK
8843 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8844 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8845 else
8846 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8847 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8849 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8851 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8853 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8854 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8856 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8857 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8858 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8859 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8860 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8862 unblock_input ();
8865 /* Mouse warping. */
8867 void
8868 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8870 int pix_x, pix_y;
8872 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8873 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8875 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8876 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8878 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8879 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8881 block_input ();
8883 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8884 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8885 unblock_input ();
8888 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8890 void
8891 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8893 block_input ();
8895 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8896 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8897 unblock_input ();
8900 /* Raise frame F. */
8902 void
8903 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8905 block_input ();
8906 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8907 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8908 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8909 unblock_input ();
8912 /* Lower frame F. */
8914 static void
8915 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8917 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8919 block_input ();
8920 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8921 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8922 unblock_input ();
8926 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8928 void
8929 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8931 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8932 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8933 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8934 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8935 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8938 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8940 void
8941 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8943 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8944 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8946 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8948 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8950 Lisp_Object frame;
8951 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8952 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8953 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8954 make_number (32),
8955 Fcons (make_number (1),
8956 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8957 Qnil)));
8961 static void
8962 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8964 if (raise_flag)
8965 x_raise_frame (f);
8966 else
8967 x_lower_frame (f);
8970 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8972 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8974 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8976 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8978 static void
8979 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8981 unsigned long data[2];
8982 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8984 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8985 data[1] = flags;
8987 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8988 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8989 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8991 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8993 static void
8994 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8995 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8997 XEvent event;
8999 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9000 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9001 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9002 event.xclient.format = 32;
9003 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9004 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9005 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9006 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9007 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9009 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9010 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9011 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9014 /* Change of visibility. */
9016 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9017 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9018 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9019 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9020 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9021 finishes with it. */
9023 void
9024 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9026 Lisp_Object type;
9027 int original_top, original_left;
9028 int retry_count = 2;
9030 retry:
9032 block_input ();
9034 type = x_icon_type (f);
9035 if (!NILP (type))
9036 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9038 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9040 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9041 call x_set_offset a second time
9042 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9043 before the window gets really visible. */
9044 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9045 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9046 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9047 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9049 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9051 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9052 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9053 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9054 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9055 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9056 else
9058 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9059 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9061 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9062 #ifdef USE_GTK
9063 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9064 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9065 #else
9066 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9067 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9068 else
9069 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9070 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9071 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9074 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9076 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9077 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9078 so that incoming events are handled. */
9080 Lisp_Object frame;
9081 int count;
9082 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9083 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9084 will set it when they are handled. */
9085 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9087 original_left = f->left_pos;
9088 original_top = f->top_pos;
9090 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9091 unblock_input ();
9093 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9095 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9096 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9097 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9098 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9100 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9101 because the window manager may choose the position
9102 and we don't want to override it. */
9104 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9105 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9106 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9107 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9108 && previously_visible)
9110 Drawable rootw;
9111 int x, y;
9112 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9114 block_input ();
9116 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9117 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9118 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9119 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9120 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9121 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9122 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9123 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9124 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9126 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9127 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9128 original_left, original_top);
9130 unblock_input ();
9133 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9135 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9136 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9137 MapNotify at all.. */
9138 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9139 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9141 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9142 x_sync (f);
9144 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9145 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9146 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9147 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9148 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9149 probably a bug. */
9150 if (input_polling_used ())
9152 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9153 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9154 handler reset it. */
9155 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9156 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9157 poll_for_input_1 ();
9158 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9162 /* 2000-09-28: In
9164 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9165 (iconify-frame f)
9166 (raise-frame f))
9168 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9169 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9170 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9171 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9173 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9174 goto retry;
9178 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9180 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9182 void
9183 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9185 Window window;
9187 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9188 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9190 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9191 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9192 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9194 block_input ();
9196 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9197 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9198 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9199 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9200 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9201 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9203 #ifdef USE_GTK
9204 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9205 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9206 else
9207 #else
9208 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9209 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9210 else
9211 #endif
9214 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9215 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9217 unblock_input ();
9218 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9222 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9223 just by the event that we get from the server.
9224 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9225 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9226 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9227 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9228 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
9230 x_sync (f);
9232 unblock_input ();
9235 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9237 void
9238 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9240 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9241 int result;
9242 #endif
9243 Lisp_Object type;
9245 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9246 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9247 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9249 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9250 return;
9252 block_input ();
9254 type = x_icon_type (f);
9255 if (!NILP (type))
9256 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9258 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9259 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9261 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9262 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9264 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9265 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9266 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9267 unblock_input ();
9268 return;
9270 #endif
9272 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9274 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9276 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9277 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9278 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9279 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9280 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9281 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9282 so we have to record it here. */
9283 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9284 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9285 unblock_input ();
9286 return;
9289 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9290 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9291 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9292 unblock_input ();
9294 if (!result)
9295 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9297 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9298 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9300 block_input ();
9301 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9302 unblock_input ();
9303 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9305 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9306 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9307 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9308 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9309 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9310 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9312 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9313 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9315 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9316 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9318 XEvent msg;
9320 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9321 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9322 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9323 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9324 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9326 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9327 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9328 False,
9329 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9330 &msg))
9332 unblock_input ();
9333 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9337 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9338 IconicState. */
9339 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9341 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9343 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9344 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9347 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9348 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9350 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9351 unblock_input ();
9352 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9356 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9358 void
9359 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9361 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9362 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9363 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9364 Lisp_Object bar;
9365 struct scroll_bar *b;
9366 #endif
9368 block_input ();
9370 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9371 commands to the X server. */
9372 if (dpyinfo->display)
9374 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9375 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9376 face. */
9377 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9378 free_frame_faces (f);
9380 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9381 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9383 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9384 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9385 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9386 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9387 toolkit scroll bars. */
9388 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9390 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9391 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9393 #endif
9395 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9396 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9397 free_frame_xic (f);
9398 #endif
9400 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9401 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9403 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9404 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9406 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9407 we are using a toolkit. */
9408 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9409 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9411 free_frame_menubar (f);
9412 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9414 #ifdef USE_GTK
9415 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9416 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9418 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9419 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9420 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9422 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9423 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9424 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9425 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9426 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9427 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9429 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9430 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9431 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9432 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9433 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9434 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9435 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9436 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9437 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9438 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9439 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9440 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9441 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9442 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9443 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9445 x_free_gcs (f);
9446 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9449 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9450 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9451 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9453 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9454 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9455 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9456 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9457 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9458 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9460 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9462 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9463 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9464 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9465 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9466 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9467 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9470 unblock_input ();
9474 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9476 static void
9477 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9479 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9481 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9482 commands to the X server. */
9483 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9484 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9486 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9490 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9492 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9493 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9494 that the window now has.
9495 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9496 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9497 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9499 #ifndef USE_GTK
9500 void
9501 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9503 XSizeHints size_hints;
9504 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9506 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9507 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9509 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9510 return;
9512 #endif
9514 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9515 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9517 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9518 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9520 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9521 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9523 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9524 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9525 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9526 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9527 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9528 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9530 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9532 int base_width, base_height;
9533 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9535 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9536 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9538 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9540 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9541 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9542 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9543 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9544 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9546 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9547 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9548 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9550 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9551 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9552 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9553 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9554 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9557 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9558 if (flags)
9560 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9561 goto no_read;
9565 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9566 long supplied_return;
9567 int value;
9569 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9570 &supplied_return);
9572 if (flags)
9573 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9574 else
9576 if (value == 0)
9577 hints.flags = 0;
9578 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9579 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9580 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9581 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9582 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9583 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9584 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9585 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9589 no_read:
9591 #ifdef PWinGravity
9592 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9593 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9595 if (user_position)
9597 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9598 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9600 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9602 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9604 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9606 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9608 static void
9609 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9611 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9612 Arg al[1];
9614 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9615 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9616 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9617 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9619 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9620 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9622 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9623 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9626 static void
9627 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9629 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9631 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9632 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9633 #endif
9635 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9637 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9638 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9639 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9640 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9642 else
9644 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9645 pixmap. */
9646 return;
9650 #ifdef USE_GTK
9652 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9653 return;
9656 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9659 Arg al[1];
9660 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9661 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9662 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9663 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9666 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9668 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9669 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9671 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9674 void
9675 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9677 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9679 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9680 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9681 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9683 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9687 /***********************************************************************
9688 Fonts
9689 ***********************************************************************/
9691 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9693 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9694 font table. */
9696 static void
9697 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9699 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9700 if (font->driver->check)
9701 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9704 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9707 /***********************************************************************
9708 Initialization
9709 ***********************************************************************/
9711 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9712 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9713 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9714 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9716 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9717 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9718 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9720 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9721 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9722 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9723 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9724 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9725 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9726 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9729 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9731 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9733 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9735 static int x_initialized;
9737 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9738 the screen number from the server number. */
9739 static int
9740 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9742 int seen_colon = 0;
9743 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9744 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9745 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9747 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9748 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9749 length_until_period++;
9751 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9752 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9753 name1 += 4;
9754 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9755 name2 += 4;
9756 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9757 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9758 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9759 name1 += system_name_length;
9760 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9761 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9762 name2 += system_name_length;
9763 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9764 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9765 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9766 name1 += length_until_period;
9767 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9768 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9769 name2 += length_until_period;
9771 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9773 if (*name1 == ':')
9774 seen_colon = 1;
9775 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9776 return 1;
9778 return (seen_colon
9779 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9780 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9783 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9784 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9785 to 5. */
9786 static void
9787 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9789 int nr = 0;
9790 int off = 0;
9792 while (!(mask & 1))
9794 off++;
9795 mask >>= 1;
9798 while (mask & 1)
9800 nr++;
9801 mask >>= 1;
9804 *offset = off;
9805 *bits = nr;
9808 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9809 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9812 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9814 int dpy_ok = 1;
9815 Display *dpy;
9817 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9818 if (dpy)
9819 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9820 else
9821 dpy_ok = 0;
9822 return dpy_ok;
9825 #ifdef USE_GTK
9826 static void
9827 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9828 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9830 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9831 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9833 #endif
9835 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9836 the structure that describes the open display.
9837 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9839 struct x_display_info *
9840 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9842 int connection;
9843 Display *dpy;
9844 struct terminal *terminal;
9845 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9846 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9847 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9848 ptrdiff_t lim;
9850 block_input ();
9852 if (!x_initialized)
9854 x_initialize ();
9855 ++x_initialized;
9858 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9859 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9861 #ifdef USE_GTK
9863 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9864 int argc;
9865 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9866 char **argv2 = argv;
9867 guint id;
9869 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9871 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9873 else
9875 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9876 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9878 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9879 argv[argc] = 0;
9881 argc = 0;
9882 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9884 if (! NILP (display_name))
9886 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9887 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9890 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9891 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9893 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9895 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9896 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9897 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9899 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9900 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9901 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9902 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9904 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9905 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9906 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9908 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9909 fixup_locale ();
9910 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9911 fixup_locale ();
9913 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9915 xg_initialize ();
9917 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9919 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9920 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9922 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9923 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9925 s = build_string (file);
9926 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9928 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9929 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9931 #endif
9933 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9934 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9937 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9938 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9939 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9940 errors with X11R5:
9941 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9942 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9943 So let's not use it until R6. */
9944 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9945 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9946 #endif
9949 int argc = 0;
9950 char *argv[3];
9952 argv[0] = "";
9953 argc = 1;
9954 if (xrm_option)
9956 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9957 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9959 turn_on_atimers (0);
9960 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9961 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9962 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9963 &argc, argv);
9964 turn_on_atimers (1);
9966 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9967 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9968 fixup_locale ();
9969 #endif
9972 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9973 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9974 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9975 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9976 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9978 /* Detect failure. */
9979 if (dpy == 0)
9981 unblock_input ();
9982 return 0;
9985 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9987 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9988 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9990 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9993 struct x_display_info *share;
9994 Lisp_Object tail;
9996 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9997 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9998 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9999 SSDATA (display_name)))
10000 break;
10001 if (share)
10002 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10003 else
10005 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10006 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10007 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10009 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10010 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10011 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10012 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10013 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10015 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10017 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10019 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10020 list of terminals. */
10021 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10022 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10023 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10024 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10026 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10027 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10028 unblock_input ();
10029 kset_system_key_alist
10030 (terminal->kboard,
10031 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10032 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10033 block_input ();
10034 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10035 terminal_list = terminal;
10036 UNGCPRO;
10039 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10040 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10041 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10042 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10043 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10045 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10048 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10049 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10050 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10052 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10053 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10054 x_display_name_list);
10055 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10057 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10059 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10060 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10061 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10062 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10064 #if 0
10065 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10066 #endif /* ! 0 */
10068 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10069 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10070 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10071 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10072 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10073 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10074 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10076 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10077 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10079 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10080 #ifdef USE_GTK
10081 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10082 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10083 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10085 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10086 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10088 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10089 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10090 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10091 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10092 #else
10093 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10094 #endif
10095 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10096 all versions. */
10097 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10099 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10100 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10101 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10102 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10103 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10104 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10105 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10106 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10107 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10108 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10109 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10110 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10111 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10112 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10113 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10114 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10115 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10116 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10117 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10118 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10119 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10120 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10122 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10123 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10124 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10125 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10127 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10128 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10129 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10131 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10133 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10134 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10135 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10136 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10137 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10138 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10141 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10142 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10144 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10146 Lisp_Object value;
10147 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10148 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10149 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10150 Qnil, Qnil);
10151 if (STRINGP (value)
10152 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10153 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10154 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10157 else
10158 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10159 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10161 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10163 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10164 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10165 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10166 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10167 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10168 for example). */
10169 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10170 double d;
10171 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10172 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10174 #endif
10176 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10178 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10179 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10180 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10181 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10182 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10183 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10184 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10185 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10186 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10190 const struct
10192 const char *name;
10193 Atom *atom;
10194 } atom_refs[] = {
10195 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10196 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10197 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10198 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10199 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10200 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10201 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10202 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10203 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10204 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10205 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10206 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10207 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10208 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10209 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10210 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10211 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10212 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10213 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10214 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10215 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10216 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10217 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10218 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10219 /* For properties of font. */
10220 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10221 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10222 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10223 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10224 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10225 /* Ghostscript support. */
10226 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10227 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10228 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10229 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10230 /* EWMH */
10231 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10232 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10233 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10234 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10235 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10236 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10237 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10238 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10239 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10240 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10241 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10242 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10243 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10244 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10245 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10246 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10247 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10248 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10249 /* Session management */
10250 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10251 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10252 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10255 int i;
10256 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10257 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10258 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10259 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10260 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10261 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10262 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10263 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10265 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10266 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10268 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10269 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10270 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10271 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10273 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10274 False, atoms_return);
10276 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10277 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10279 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10280 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10282 xfree (atom_names);
10283 xfree (atoms_return);
10286 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10287 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10288 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10289 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10291 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10292 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10293 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10295 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10296 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10297 dpyinfo->gray
10298 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10299 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10300 1, 0, 1);
10302 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10303 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10304 #endif
10306 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10308 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10309 if (connection != 0)
10310 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10312 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10313 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10314 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10316 if (interrupt_input)
10317 init_sigio (connection);
10319 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10321 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10322 Font font;
10324 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10325 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10326 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10327 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10328 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10329 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10330 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10331 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10332 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10333 emacs_abort ();
10334 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10335 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10336 x_uncatch_errors ();
10338 #endif
10340 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10341 for debugging X code. */
10343 Lisp_Object value;
10344 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10345 build_string ("synchronous"),
10346 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10347 Qnil, Qnil);
10348 if (STRINGP (value)
10349 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10350 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10351 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10355 Lisp_Object value;
10356 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10357 build_string ("useXIM"),
10358 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10359 Qnil, Qnil);
10360 #ifdef USE_XIM
10361 if (STRINGP (value)
10362 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10363 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10364 use_xim = 0;
10365 #else
10366 if (STRINGP (value)
10367 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10368 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10369 use_xim = 1;
10370 #endif
10373 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10374 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10375 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10376 tty. */
10377 if (terminal->id == 1)
10378 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10379 #endif
10381 unblock_input ();
10383 return dpyinfo;
10386 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10387 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10389 static void
10390 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10392 struct terminal *t;
10394 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10395 X display. */
10396 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10397 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10399 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10400 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10401 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10402 x_session_close ();
10403 #endif
10404 delete_terminal (t);
10405 break;
10408 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10410 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10411 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10412 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10413 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10414 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10415 else
10417 Lisp_Object tail;
10419 tail = x_display_name_list;
10420 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10422 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10424 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10425 break;
10427 tail = XCDR (tail);
10431 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10432 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10434 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10435 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10436 else
10438 struct x_display_info *tail;
10440 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10441 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10442 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10445 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10446 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10447 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10448 xfree (dpyinfo);
10451 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10453 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10454 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10455 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10456 that slows us down. */
10458 static void
10459 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10461 block_input ();
10462 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10463 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10465 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10466 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10467 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10468 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10470 unblock_input ();
10473 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10474 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10475 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10476 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10477 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10478 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10479 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10481 void
10482 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10484 block_input ();
10485 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10487 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10488 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10489 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10491 unblock_input ();
10494 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10497 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10499 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10501 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10502 x_produce_glyphs,
10503 x_write_glyphs,
10504 x_insert_glyphs,
10505 x_clear_end_of_line,
10506 x_scroll_run,
10507 x_after_update_window_line,
10508 x_update_window_begin,
10509 x_update_window_end,
10510 x_cursor_to,
10511 x_flush,
10512 #ifdef XFlush
10513 x_flush,
10514 #else
10515 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10516 #endif
10517 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10518 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10519 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10520 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10521 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10522 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10523 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10524 x_draw_glyph_string,
10525 x_define_frame_cursor,
10526 x_clear_frame_area,
10527 x_draw_window_cursor,
10528 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10529 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10533 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10534 void
10535 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10537 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10539 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10540 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10541 if (!terminal->name)
10542 return;
10544 block_input ();
10545 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10546 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10547 X display. */
10548 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10549 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10550 #endif
10552 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10553 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10554 if (dpyinfo->display)
10556 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10557 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10559 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10560 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10561 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10562 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10564 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10565 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10566 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10567 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10568 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10569 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10570 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10571 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10572 leaks in other situations. */
10573 #if 0
10574 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10575 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10576 #else
10577 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10578 #endif
10579 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10580 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10581 closing all the displays. */
10582 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10583 #endif
10585 #ifdef USE_GTK
10586 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10587 #else
10588 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10589 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10590 #else
10591 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10592 #endif
10593 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10596 /* Mark as dead. */
10597 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10598 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10599 unblock_input ();
10602 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10603 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10605 static struct terminal *
10606 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10608 struct terminal *terminal;
10610 terminal = create_terminal ();
10612 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10613 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10614 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10616 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10618 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10619 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10620 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10621 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10622 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10623 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10624 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10625 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10626 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10627 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10628 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10629 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10630 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10631 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10632 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10633 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10634 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10635 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10636 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10637 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10639 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10640 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10642 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10643 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10644 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10645 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10646 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10647 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10648 off the bottom. */
10650 return terminal;
10653 void
10654 x_initialize (void)
10656 baud_rate = 19200;
10658 x_noop_count = 0;
10659 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10660 any_help_event_p = 0;
10661 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10663 #ifdef USE_GTK
10664 current_count = -1;
10665 #endif
10667 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10668 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10670 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10671 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10673 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10675 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10676 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10677 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10678 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10679 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10680 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10681 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10683 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10684 #endif
10686 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10687 #ifndef USE_GTK
10688 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10689 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10690 #endif
10691 #endif
10693 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10694 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10695 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10697 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10698 original error handler. */
10699 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10700 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10704 void
10705 syms_of_xterm (void)
10707 x_error_message = NULL;
10709 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10710 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10712 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10713 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10715 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10716 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10718 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10719 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10721 #ifdef USE_GTK
10722 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10723 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10725 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10726 #endif
10728 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10729 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10730 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10731 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10732 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10733 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10734 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10735 sizes. */);
10736 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10738 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10739 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10740 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10741 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10742 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10743 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10744 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10746 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10747 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10748 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10749 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10750 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10751 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10752 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10753 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10754 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10756 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10757 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10758 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10759 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10760 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10761 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10762 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10763 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10764 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10765 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10766 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10767 #elif USE_GTK
10768 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10769 #else
10770 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10771 #endif
10772 #else
10773 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10774 #endif
10776 DEFVAR_BOOL ("scroll-bar-adjust-thumb-portion",
10777 scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p,
10778 doc: /* Adjust thumb for overscrolling for Gtk+ and MOTIF.
10779 Non-nil means adjust the thumb in the scroll bar so it can be dragged downwards
10780 even if the end of the buffer is shown (i.e. overscrolling).
10781 Set to nil if you want the thumb to be at the bottom when the end of the buffer
10782 is shown. Also, the thumb fills the whole scroll bar when the entire buffer
10783 is visible. In this case you can not overscroll. */);
10784 scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p = 1;
10786 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10787 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10789 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10790 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10791 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10792 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10793 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10794 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10795 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10796 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10797 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10799 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10800 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10801 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10802 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10803 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10804 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10806 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10807 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10808 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10809 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10810 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10811 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10814 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10817 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10818 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10821 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10822 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10823 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10824 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10825 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10828 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10829 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10830 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10831 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10832 Qnil);
10835 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */